blob: 8da3846f691c6764287298735c829b6e7fe9125e [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
351
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000352/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
353/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000354/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000355/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
356/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
357/// GCC.
358QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
359 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000361 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000362
363 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000364
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000367 QualType lhs =
368 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000369 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000370 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000371
372 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
373 if (lhs == rhs)
374 return lhs;
375
376 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
377 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
378 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
379 return lhs;
380
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000381 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000382 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000383 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
384 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000385 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000386 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
387 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
388
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000389 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000390 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000391 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
392 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000393 return destType;
394}
395
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000396//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
397// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
398//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
399
400
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000401/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000402/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
403/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
404/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
405/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000406///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000407ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000408Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000409 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
410
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000411 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000412 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000413 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000414
415 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
416 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
417 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000418
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000420 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000421 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000422
423 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000424 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000425 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000426
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000427 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
428 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
429 // strings.
430 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000431 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000432 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000433
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000434 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000435 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
436 Literal.GetStringLength(),
437 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
438 &StringTokLocs[0],
439 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000440}
441
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000442/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
443/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
444/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
445/// for values inside the block or for globals).
446///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000447/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448/// up-to-date.
449///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000450static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000451 ValueDecl *VD) {
452 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
453 // we wanted to.
454 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
455 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000457 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
458 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
459 return false;
460
461 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
462 // snapshot it.
463 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
464 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000465 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
466 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000468 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
469 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
470
471 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
472 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
473 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
474 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000475 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
476 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000477
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000478 if (!NextBlock)
479 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000480
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000481 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
482 // having a reference outside it.
483 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
484 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000486 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
487 // a snapshot as well.
488 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000491 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492}
493
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000494
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000497 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000498 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
499 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
500}
501
502/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000503ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
505 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
506 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000507 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000510 << D->getDeclName();
511 return ExprError();
512 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000513
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000514 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
516 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
517 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000518 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000519 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
521 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000522 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
523 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000524 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000525 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000526 << D->getIdentifier();
527 return ExprError();
528 }
529 }
530 }
531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000533 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000534
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000535 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
536 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
537 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000538 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000539}
540
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
542/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
543/// actual member.
544///
545/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
546/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
547/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
548/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
549/// we found.
550///
551/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
552/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
553/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
554VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
555 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000556 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
557 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
558 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
559
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
562 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
563 do {
564 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000565 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 else {
569 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
570 break;
571 }
572 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000573 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000574 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000575
576 return BaseObject;
577}
578
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000579ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000580Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
581 FieldDecl *Field,
582 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
583 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
584 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000585 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000586 AnonFields);
587
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
589 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
590 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
591 // found via name lookup.
592 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000593 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 if (BaseObject) {
595 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
596 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000597 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000599 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000600 BaseQuals
601 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
603 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
604 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
605 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
606 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000607 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
609 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
610 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals
612 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 } else {
614 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
615 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
616 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000617 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
618 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 = Context.getTagDeclType(
622 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
623 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000624 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000625 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
626 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
627 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000628 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000629 MD->getThisType(Context),
630 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000631 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
632 }
633 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000634 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
635 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000636 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000637 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000638 }
639
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000640 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000641 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
642 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 }
644
645 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
646 // anonymous struct/union.
647 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
650 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
651 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
652 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000653 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
654 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
655
656 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
657 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
658 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
659 ResultQuals.removeConst();
660
661 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
662 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
663
664 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
665 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
666
667 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
668 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
669 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
670
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000671 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000672 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000673 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000674 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
675 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000676 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000677 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000678 }
679
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000680 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000681}
682
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000683/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684/// possibly a list of template arguments.
685///
686/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
687/// DecomposeTemplateName.
688///
689/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
690/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
691/// some way.
692static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
693 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
694 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000695 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000696 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
697 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
698 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
699 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
700
701 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
702 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
703 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
704 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
705 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
706
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000707 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
709 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000710 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
711 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000712 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000713 TemplateArgs = 0;
714 }
715}
716
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
718/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
719/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
722 return false;
723
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
725 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
726 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
727 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
728 if (!BaseRT) return false;
729
730 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000731 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
738
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
893 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
928 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000929 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000930 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000931 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
933 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
934 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
935 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
936 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
937 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
938 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
939 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
940 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
941 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
942 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
943 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
944 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
945 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000947 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
948 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
949 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000950 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000951 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000953 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000954
955 // Do we really want to note all of these?
956 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
957 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000962
963 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000964 }
965 }
966
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000967 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000969 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000970 if (!R.empty()) {
971 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
972 if (SS.isEmpty())
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
974 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
975 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
976 else
977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
978 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
979 << SS.getRange()
980 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
981 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
982 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
983 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
984 << ND->getDeclName();
985
986 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
987 return false;
988 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000989
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000990 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
991 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
992 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
993 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
994 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
995 // to recover well anyway.
996 if (SS.isEmpty())
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
998 else
999 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1000 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1001 << SS.getRange();
1002
1003 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1004 return true;
1005 }
1006 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001007 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001008 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001010 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001011 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001012 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001013 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1014 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001015 return true;
1016 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001017 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001018 }
1019
1020 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1021 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1022 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1023 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1024 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1025 << SS.getRange();
1026 return true;
1027 }
1028
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001029 // Give up, we can't recover.
1030 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1031 return true;
1032}
1033
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001034ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1035 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001036 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1037 if (!IDecl)
1038 return 0;
1039 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1040 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1041 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001042 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001043 if (!property)
1044 return 0;
1045 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001046 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1047 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001048 return 0;
1049 return property;
1050}
1051
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001052bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1053 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1054 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1055 if (!IDecl)
1056 return false;
1057 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1058 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1059 return false;
1060 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1061 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1062 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1063 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1064 return false;
1065
1066 return true;
1067}
1068
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001069static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001070 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001071 IdentifierInfo *II,
1072 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1073 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001074 bool LookForIvars;
1075 if (Lookup.empty())
1076 LookForIvars = true;
1077 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1078 LookForIvars = false;
1079 else
1080 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1081 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1082 if (!LookForIvars)
1083 return 0;
1084
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001085 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1086 if (!IDecl)
1087 return 0;
1088 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001089 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1090 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001091 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1092 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1093 if (!property)
1094 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001095 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001096 DynamicImplSeen =
1097 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001098 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1099 // one.
1100 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1101 return 0;
1102 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001103 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001104 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1105 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001106 NameLoc,
1107 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1108 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1109 (Expr *)0, true);
1110 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1111 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1112 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1113 return Ivar;
1114 }
1115 return 0;
1116}
1117
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001118ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001119 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1120 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1121 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1122 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1124 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1125
1126 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001127 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001128
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001129 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130
1131 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001132 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001134 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001135
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001136 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001137 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001138 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001139
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1141 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001142 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1143 // (note: handled after lookup)
1144 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1145 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1146 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001147 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1148 // names a dependent type.
1149 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1150 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001151 bool DependentID = false;
1152 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1153 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1154 DependentID = true;
1155 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1156 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1157 if (DC) {
1158 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1159 return ExprError();
1160 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1161 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1162 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1163 } else {
1164 DependentID = true;
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001169 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 TemplateArgs);
1171 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001172 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001174 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001176 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1177 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1178 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1179 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1180 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001181 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1182 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1183 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001185 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001186 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001187
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1189 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001190 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001191 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001192 if (E.isInvalid())
1193 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001194
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1196 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001197 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1198 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001199 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001200 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1201 isAddressOfOperand);
1202 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001203 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1204 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001205 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001206 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001207
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001211 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1212 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001214
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001216 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001217 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1218 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1219 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1220 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1221 }
1222
1223 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1224 // call, diagnose the problem.
1225 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001226 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001227 return ExprError();
1228
1229 assert(!R.empty() &&
1230 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001231
1232 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1233 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001234 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001235 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1236 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001237 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001238 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1239 return move(E);
1240 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001241 }
1242 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001243
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001244 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1245 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1246
1247 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001248 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001249 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1250 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001251 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001252 if (Property) {
1253 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1254 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001255 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001256 }
1257 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001258 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001259 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1260 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1261 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1262 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1263 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1264 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001265 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001266 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001267
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001268 QualType T = Func->getType();
1269 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001270 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001271 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1272 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001274 }
1275 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001276
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001277 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001278 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1279 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1280 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1281 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1282 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1283 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1284 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1285 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001286 //
1287 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1288 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1289 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1290 // non-static member function:
1291 //
1292 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1293 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1294 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1295 // member function call.
1296 //
1297 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1298 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1299 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1300 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001301 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001302 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1303 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1304 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1305 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1306 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1307 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1308 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001309 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1310 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001311 else
1312 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1313
1314 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001315 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001316 }
1317
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 if (TemplateArgs)
1319 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001320
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1322}
1323
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001324/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001325ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001326Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1327 LookupResult &R,
1328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1329 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1330 case IMA_Instance:
1331 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1332
1333 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1334 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1335 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1336 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1337
1338 case IMA_Mixed:
1339 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1340 case IMA_Unresolved:
1341 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1342
1343 case IMA_Static:
1344 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1345 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1346 if (TemplateArgs)
1347 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1348 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1349
1350 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1351 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1352 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1353 return ExprError();
1354 }
1355
1356 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1357 return ExprError();
1358}
1359
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001360/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1361/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1362/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1363/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001364ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001365Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001366 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001368 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001369 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001371 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001372 return ExprError();
1373
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001374 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1376
1377 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1378 return ExprError();
1379
1380 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001381 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1382 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 return ExprError();
1384 }
1385
1386 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1387}
1388
1389/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1390/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1391/// additional lookup.
1392///
1393/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1394/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1395///
1396/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001397ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001398Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001399 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001400 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001401 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001402
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001403 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1404 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1405 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1406 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1407 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1408
1409 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1410 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1411 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001412 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001413
1414 bool LookForIvars;
1415 if (Lookup.empty())
1416 LookForIvars = true;
1417 else if (IsClassMethod)
1418 LookForIvars = false;
1419 else
1420 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1421 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001422 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001424 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1426 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1427 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1428 if (IsClassMethod)
1429 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1430 << IV->getDeclName());
1431
1432 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1433 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1434 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1435 return ExprError();
1436
1437 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1438 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1439 return ExprError();
1440
1441 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1442 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1443 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1444 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1445
1446 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1447 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1448 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1449 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001450 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001451 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001452 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001453 SelfName, false, false);
1454 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1455 return ExprError();
1456
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001457 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1458 return Owned(new (Context)
1459 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1460 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1461 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001462 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001464 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001465 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1466 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1467 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1468 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1469 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1470 }
1471 }
1472
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001473 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1474 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1475 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1476 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1477 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1478 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1479 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1480 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1481 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1482 }
1483 }
1484 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001485 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1486 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001487}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001488
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001489/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1490///
1491/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1492///
1493/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1494/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1495/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1496/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1497///
1498/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1499/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1500/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1501/// the class declaring the member.
1502///
1503/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1504/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1505/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001506bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1508 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 NamedDecl *Member) {
1511 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1512 if (!RD)
1513 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 QualType DestRecordType;
1516 QualType DestType;
1517 QualType FromRecordType;
1518 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1519 bool PointerConversions = false;
1520 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1521 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001523 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1524 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1525 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1526 PointerConversions = true;
1527 } else {
1528 DestType = DestRecordType;
1529 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001530 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1532 if (Method->isStatic())
1533 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001534
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001535 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1536 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001537
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001538 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1539 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1540 PointerConversions = true;
1541 } else {
1542 FromRecordType = FromType;
1543 DestType = DestRecordType;
1544 }
1545 } else {
1546 // No conversion necessary.
1547 return false;
1548 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001549
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1551 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001552
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1554 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1555 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001556
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001557 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1558 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1559
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001560 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001561
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001564 // class name.
1565 //
1566 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1567 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1568 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1569 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1570 //
1571 // class Base { public: int x; };
1572 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1573 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1574 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1575 //
1576 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1577 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1578 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1579 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001580 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1582 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1583 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1584
1585 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1586
1587 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1588 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1589 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1590 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001591 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001592 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001593 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 return true;
1595
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001596 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001597 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001598 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1599 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001600
1601 FromType = QType;
1602 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1603
1604 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1605 // we're done.
1606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1607 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001608 }
1609 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001610
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001611 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001612
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001613 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1614 // down to the using declaration's type.
1615 //
1616 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1617 // class ever has member declarations.
1618 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1619 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1620 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1621 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1622
1623 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1624 // conversion is non-trivial.
1625 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1626 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001627 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001628 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001629 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001630 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001631
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001632 QualType UType = URecordType;
1633 if (PointerConversions)
1634 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001635 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001636 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001637 FromType = UType;
1638 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1639 }
1640
1641 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1642 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1643 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001644 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001645
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001646 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001647 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1648 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001649 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001650 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001651
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001652 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001653 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001654 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001655}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001656
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001657/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001658static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001659 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001660 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001661 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1662 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1664 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1665 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001666 if (SS.isSet()) {
1667 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1668 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001670
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001672 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1673 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001674}
1675
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001676/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1677/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1678/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1679/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001680ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001681Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1682 LookupResult &R,
1683 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1684 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001685 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1686
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001688
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001689 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1690 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001691 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001692 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001693 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001694 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001695 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001696
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001697 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1698 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001699 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1700 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001701 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1702 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001703 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1704 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1705 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1706 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001707 }
1708
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001709 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001710 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1711 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001712 SS,
1713 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1714 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001715}
1716
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001717bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001718 const LookupResult &R,
1719 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1721 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1722 return false;
1723
1724 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001725 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001726 return false;
1727
1728 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001729 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001730 return false;
1731
1732 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1733 // normal lookup:
1734 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1735 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1736
1737 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1738 // -- a declaration of a class member
1739 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1740 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001741 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001742 return false;
1743
1744 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1745 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1746 // using-declaration
1747 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1748 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1749 // turn off ADL anyway).
1750 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1751 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1752 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1753 return false;
1754
1755 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1756 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1757 // template
1758 // And also for builtin functions.
1759 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1760 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1761
1762 // But also builtin functions.
1763 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1764 return false;
1765 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1766 return false;
1767 }
1768
1769 return true;
1770}
1771
1772
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1774/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1775/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1776/// will in fact be used.
1777static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1778 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1779 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1780 return true;
1781 }
1782
1783 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1784 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1785 return true;
1786 }
1787
1788 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1789 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1790 return true;
1791 }
1792
1793 return false;
1794}
1795
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001796ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001797Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001798 LookupResult &R,
1799 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001800 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1801 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001802 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001803 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1804 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001805
1806 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1807 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1808 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001809 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1810 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811 return ExprError();
1812
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001813 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1814 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1815 // we've picked a target.
1816 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1817
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001818 bool Dependent
1819 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001821 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001822 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001823 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001824 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1825 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001826
1827 return Owned(ULE);
1828}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001829
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001830
1831/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001832ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001833Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001834 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1835 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001836 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001837 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1838 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001839
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001840 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001841 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1842 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001843
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001844 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1845 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1846 // a template argument list.
1847 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1848 << Template << SS.getRange();
1849 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1850 return ExprError();
1851 }
1852
1853 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1854 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1855 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001856 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001857 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001858 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001859 return ExprError();
1860 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001862 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1863 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1864 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1865 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001866 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001867 return ExprError();
1868
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001869 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1870 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871 return ExprError();
1872
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001873 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1874 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1875 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1876 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001877 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001878 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1879 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1880 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001881 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001882 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001883 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1884 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1885 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1886 return ExprError();
1887 }
1888
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001889 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001890 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1891 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1892 return ExprError();
1893 }
1894
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001895 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001896 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001897 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001898 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001899 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001900 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1901 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001902 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001904 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001905 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001906 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1907 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001908 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1910 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1911 Expr *E = new (Context)
1912 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1913 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00001914 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
1915 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
1916 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001917 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001918 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001919 SourceLocation(),
1920 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00001921 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1922 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
1923 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1924 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1925 }
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001926 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001927 }
1928 }
1929 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001930 }
1931 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1932 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001933
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001934 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1935 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001936}
1937
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001938ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001939 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001940 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001942 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001943 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001944 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1945 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1946 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001947 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001948
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001949 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1950 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001951
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001952 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001953 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1954 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001955 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001956 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001957 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001958 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001960 QualType ResTy;
1961 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1962 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1963 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001964 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001966 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001967 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001968 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1969 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001970 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001971}
1972
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001973ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001974 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001975 bool Invalid = false;
1976 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1977 if (Invalid)
1978 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001980 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1981 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001982 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001983 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001984
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001985 QualType Ty;
1986 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1987 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1988 else if (Literal.isWide())
1989 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001990 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1991 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001992 else
1993 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001994
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001995 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1996 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001997 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001998}
1999
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002000ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002001 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002002 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2003 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002004 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002005 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002006 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002007 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002008 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002009
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002010 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002011 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2012 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002013 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002014
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002015 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002016 bool Invalid = false;
2017 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2018 if (Invalid)
2019 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002020
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002021 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002022 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2023 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002024 return ExprError();
2025
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002026 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002027
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002028 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002029 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002030 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002031 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002032 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002033 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002034 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002035 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002036
2037 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2038
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002039 using llvm::APFloat;
2040 APFloat Val(Format);
2041
2042 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002043
2044 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2045 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2046 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2047 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002048 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002049 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002050 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002051 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002052 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2053 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002054 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002055 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2056 }
2057
2058 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2059 << Ty
2060 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2061 }
2062
2063 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002064 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002066 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002068 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002069 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002070
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002071 // long long is a C99 feature.
2072 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002073 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002074 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2075
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002076 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002077 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002078
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002079 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2080 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2081 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002082 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2083 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002084 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002085 } else {
2086 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2087 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2090 // be an unsigned int.
2091 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2092
2093 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002094 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002095 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2096 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002099 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2100 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2101 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2102 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002103 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002104 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002107 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002108 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002109
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002110 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002111 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002112 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002113
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002114 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2115 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2116 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2117 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002118 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002119 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002120 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002121 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002122 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002123 }
2124
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002125 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002126 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002127 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002128
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002129 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2130 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2131 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2132 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002133 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002134 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002135 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002136 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002137 }
2138 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002139
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002140 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2141 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002142 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002143 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002144 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002145 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002146 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002147
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002148 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2149 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002150 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002151 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002152 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002153
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002154 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2155 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002156 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002157 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002158
2159 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002160}
2161
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002162ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002163 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002164 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002165 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002166}
2167
2168/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2169/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002170bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002171 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002172 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002173 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002174 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2175 return false;
2176
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002177 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2178 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2179 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2180 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2181 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2182 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2183
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002184 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002185 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002186 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002187 if (isSizeof)
2188 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2189 return false;
2190 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002191
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002192 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002193 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002194 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2195 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002196 return false;
2197 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002198
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002199 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002200 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2201 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002202 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002203
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002204 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002205 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002206 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002207 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2208 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002209 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002211 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002212}
2213
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002214static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2215 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002216 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002217
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002219 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2220 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002221
2222 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2223 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2224 return false;
2225
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002226 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002227 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002228 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002229 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002230
2231 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2232 // bit-field.
2233 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002234 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002235 return false;
2236
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002237 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002238}
2239
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002240/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002242Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002243 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002244 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002245 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002246 return ExprError();
2247
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002248 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002249
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002250 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2251 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2252 return ExprError();
2253
2254 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002256 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2257 R.getEnd()));
2258}
2259
2260/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2261/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002262ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002263Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002264 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2265 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2266 bool isInvalid = false;
2267 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2268 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2269 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002270 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002271 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002272 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2273 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002274 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2275 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2276 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2277 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002278 } else {
2279 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2280 }
2281
2282 if (isInvalid)
2283 return ExprError();
2284
2285 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2286 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2287 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2288 R.getEnd()));
2289}
2290
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002291/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2292/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2293/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002294ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002295Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2296 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002297 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002298 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002299
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002300 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002301 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002302 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002303 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002305
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002306 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002307 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002308 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2309
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002310 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002311}
2312
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002313QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002314 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2315 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002317 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002318 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002319 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002321 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2322 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2323 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002325 // Test for placeholders.
2326 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2327 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2328 if (PR.take() != V) {
2329 V = PR.take();
2330 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2331 }
2332
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002333 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002334 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2335 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002336 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002337}
2338
2339
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002340
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002341ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002342Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002343 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002344 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002345 switch (Kind) {
2346 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002347 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2348 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002349 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002350
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002351 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002352}
2353
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002354ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002355Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2356 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002357 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002358 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002359 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2360 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002361
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002362 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002363
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002364 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002365 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002366 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2367 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2368 }
2369
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002370 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002371 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002372 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2373 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2374 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002375 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002376 }
2377
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002378 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002379}
2380
2381
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002382ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002383Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2384 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2385 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2386 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002387
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002388 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002389 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2390 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2391 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002392
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002393 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002394
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002395 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002396 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002397 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002398 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002399 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2400 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002401 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2402 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2403 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2404 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002405 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002406 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2407 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002408 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002409 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002410 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002411 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2412 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002413 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002414 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002415 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002416 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2417 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2418 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002419 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002420 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002421 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2422 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2423 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2424 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002425 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002426 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002427 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002428
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002429 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2430 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002431 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2432 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002433 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002434 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2435 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2436 // force the promotion here.
2437 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2438 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002439 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002440 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002441 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2442
2443 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2444 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002445 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002446 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2447 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2448 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2449 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002450 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002451 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002452 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2453
2454 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2455 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002456 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002457 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002458 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2459 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002460 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002461 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002462 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002463 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2464 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002465
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002466 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002467 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2468 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002469 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2470
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002471 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002472 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2473 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002474 // incomplete types are not object types.
2475 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2476 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2477 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2478 return ExprError();
2479 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002480
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002481 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2482 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2483 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2484 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2485 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002486 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002487 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2488 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002489 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002490
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002491 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002492 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002493 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2494 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2495 return ExprError();
2496 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002497
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002498 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002499 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002500}
2501
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002502QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002503CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002504 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002505 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002506 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2507 // see FIXME there.
2508 //
2509 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2510 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002511 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002512
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002513 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002514 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002515
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002516 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002517 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2518 // to be selected.
2519 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002520
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002521 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2522 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002523 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002524
2525 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2526 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002527 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002528 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2529 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002530 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002531 do
2532 compStr++;
2533 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002534 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002535 do
2536 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002537 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002538 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002539
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002540 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002541 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2542 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002543 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002544 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002545 return QualType();
2546 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002547
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002548 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2549 // operates on.
2550 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002551 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002552
2553 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002554 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002555
2556 while (*compStr) {
2557 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2558 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2559 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2560 return QualType();
2561 }
2562 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002563 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002564
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002565 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002566 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002567 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002568 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002569 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002570 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002571 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002572 if (HexSwizzle)
2573 CompSize--;
2574
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002575 if (CompSize == 1)
2576 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002577
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002578 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002579 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002580 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2581 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2582 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2583 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002584 }
2585 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002586}
2587
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002588static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002589 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002590 const Selector &Sel,
2591 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002592 if (Member)
2593 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2594 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002595 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002596 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002597
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002598 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2599 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002600 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2601 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002602 return D;
2603 }
2604 return 0;
2605}
2606
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002607static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2608 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2609 const Selector &Sel,
2610 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002611 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2612 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002613 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002614 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002615 if (Member)
2616 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2617 GDecl = PD;
2618 break;
2619 }
2620 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002621 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002622 GDecl = OMD;
2623 break;
2624 }
2625 }
2626 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002627 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002628 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2629 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002630 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2631 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002632 if (GDecl)
2633 return GDecl;
2634 }
2635 }
2636 return GDecl;
2637}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002638
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002639ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002640Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002641 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2643 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002644 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002645 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002646 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2647 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2648 //
2649 // T* t;
2650 // t.f;
2651 //
2652 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2653 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2654 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2655 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2658 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002660 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002661 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662 return ExprError();
2663 }
2664 }
2665
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002666 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2667 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002668 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002669
2670 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2671 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002674 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002675 SS.getRange(),
2676 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002677 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678}
2679
2680/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2681/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2682/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2683static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2684 Expr *BaseExpr,
2685 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002688 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2689 // diagnostics.
2690 if (!BaseExpr)
2691 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002692
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002693 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2694 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695}
2696
2697// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2698// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2699// type. The restriction here is:
2700//
2701// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2702// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2703// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2704//
2705// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2706// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2707// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2708// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2709bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2710 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002711 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002712 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2714 if (!BaseRT) {
2715 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2716 // dependent.
2717 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2718 return false;
2719 }
2720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002721
2722 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2724 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002725 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002729 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2730 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2731 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002733 if (!DC->isRecord())
2734 continue;
2735
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002736 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002737 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002738
2739 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2740 return false;
2741 }
2742
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002743 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 return true;
2745}
2746
2747static bool
2748LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2749 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002750 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2751 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002752 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2753 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002754 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755 << BaseRange))
2756 return true;
2757
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002758 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2759 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2760 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2761
2762 bool MOUS;
2763 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2764 return false;
2765 }
2766
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002767 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2768 if (SS.isSet()) {
2769 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2770 // nested-name-specifier.
2771 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2772
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002773 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002774 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2775 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2776 return true;
2777 }
2778
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002780
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002781 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2782 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2783 << DC << SS.getRange();
2784 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002785 }
2786 }
2787
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002788 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2789 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002791 if (!R.empty())
2792 return false;
2793
2794 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2795 // for typos.
2796 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002797 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002798 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002799 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2800 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2801 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002802 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2803 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002804 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2805 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2806 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002807 return false;
2808 } else {
2809 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002810 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002811 }
2812
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002813 return false;
2814}
2815
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002816ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002817Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002819 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002821 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002823 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2824 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002825 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2827 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002828 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002830 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002832 // Implicit member accesses.
2833 if (!Base) {
2834 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2835 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2836 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2837 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002838 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002839 return ExprError();
2840
2841 // Explicit member accesses.
2842 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002843 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002844 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002845 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002846
2847 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2848 Owned(Base);
2849 return ExprError();
2850 }
2851
2852 if (Result.get())
2853 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002854
2855 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2856 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857 }
2858
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002859 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002860 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2861 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862}
2863
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002864ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002865Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002866 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2867 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002868 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002870 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2871 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002872 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 if (IsArrow) {
2874 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2875 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2876 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002877 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002878
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002879 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002880 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2881 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2882 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883
2884 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002885 return ExprError();
2886
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 if (R.empty()) {
2888 // Rederive where we looked up.
2889 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2890 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2891 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002892
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002893 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002894 << MemberName << DC
2895 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 return ExprError();
2897 }
2898
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002899 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2900 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2901 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2902 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2903 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2904 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2905 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2906 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2907 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2908 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002909 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002910 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002911 return ExprError();
2912
2913 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2914 // result.
2915 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002916 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002917 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002918 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002919 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002920
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002921 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2922 // pick a member.
2923 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2924
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002925 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2926 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2927 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002928 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2929 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002930 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002931 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002932 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933
2934 return Owned(MemExpr);
2935 }
2936
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002937 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002938 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002939 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2940
2941 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2942
2943 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2944 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2945 // error cases.
2946 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2947 return ExprError();
2948
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002949 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2950 if (!BaseExpr) {
2951 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002952 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002953 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002954
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002955 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2956 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2957 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2958 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002959 }
2960
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2962 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2963 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2964 // explicitly qualified.
2965 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2966 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2967 }
2968
2969 // Check the use of this member.
2970 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2971 Owned(BaseExpr);
2972 return ExprError();
2973 }
2974
2975 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2976 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2977 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002978 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2979 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002980 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2981 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2982
2983 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2984 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2985 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2986 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2987 else {
2988 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2989 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2990 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2991
2992 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2993 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2994
2995 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2996 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2997 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2998 }
2999
3000 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003001 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 return ExprError();
3003 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003004 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3005 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 }
3007
3008 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3009 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3010 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003011 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003012 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3013 }
3014
3015 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3016 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3017 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003018 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003019 MemberFn->getType()));
3020 }
3021
3022 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3023 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3024 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003025 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3026 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003027 }
3028
3029 Owned(BaseExpr);
3030
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003031 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003033 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003034 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3035 else
3036 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3037 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003038
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003039 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3040 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003041 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003042 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003043}
3044
3045/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3046/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3047/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3048/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3049/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3050/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3051/// an ordinary member expression.
3052///
3053/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3054/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003055ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003056Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003057 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003058 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003059 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003060 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003061
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003062 // Perform default conversions.
3063 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003064
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003065 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3067
3068 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3069 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003070
3071 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003073 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3074 // call, and continue on.
3075 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3076 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3077 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3078 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3079 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3081 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003082 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3083 ->isRecordType()))) {
3084 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003085 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003086 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003087 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003088
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003089 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003090 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003091 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003092 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003093 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003094
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003095 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3096 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3097 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3098 }
3099 }
3100 }
3101
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003102 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3103 // use that.
3104 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003105 if (IsArrow) {
3106 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3107 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3108 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003109 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003110 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003111 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3112 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003113 }
3114 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003115 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3116 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3117 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3118 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003119 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003120 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003121 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003122
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003123 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3124 // use that.
3125 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3126 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3127 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3128 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3129 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003130 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003131 }
3132 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003134 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003135
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003136 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003137 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003138 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3139 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3140 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3141 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3142 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3143 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3144 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3145 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3146 // Check the use of this method.
3147 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3148 return ExprError();
3149 }
3150 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3151 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3152 Selector SetterSel =
3153 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3154 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3155 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3156 if (!Setter) {
3157 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3158 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003159 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003160 }
3161 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3162 if (!Setter)
3163 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3166 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003167
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003168 if (Getter || Setter) {
3169 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003170
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003171 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003172 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003173 else
3174 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3175 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3176 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003177 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003178 PType,
3179 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3180 }
3181 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3182 << MemberName << BaseType);
3183 }
3184 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003185
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003186 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3187 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3188 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003189 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003190 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003191
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003192 if (IsArrow) {
3193 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003194 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003195 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3196 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003197 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3198 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3199 // struct MyRecord foo;
3200 // foo->bar
3201 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3202 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3203 // by now.
3204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3205 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003206 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003207 IsArrow = false;
3208 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003209 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3210 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3211 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003212 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003213 } else {
3214 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3215 // type *foo;
3216 // foo.bar
3217 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3218 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3219 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3220 // the appropriate pointer type
3221 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3222 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3223 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3225 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003226 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003227 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3228 IsArrow = true;
3229 }
3230 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003231 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003232
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003233 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003234 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003235 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003236 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003237 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003238 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003239 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003240
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003241 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3242 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003243 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003244 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003245 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003246 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3247 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3248 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3249 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003250 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3251
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003253 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003254
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003255 if (!IV) {
3256 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3257 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3258 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003259 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3260 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3261 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003262 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003263 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003264 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3265 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003266 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3267 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003268 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003269 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003270 } else {
3271 Res.clear();
3272 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003273 }
3274 }
3275
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003276 if (IV) {
3277 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3278 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3279 // error cases.
3280 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3281 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003282
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003283 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3284 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3285 return ExprError();
3286 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3287 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3288 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3289 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3290 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3291 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3292 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3293 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3294 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3295 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3296 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3297 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003298 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003299 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003300 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3301 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003302 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003303 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3304 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003305
3306 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3307 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003308 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003309 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003310 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003311 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3312 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003313 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003314 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003315 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003316
3317 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3318 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003319 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003320 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003321 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003322 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003323 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003324 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003325 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003326 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003327 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3328 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003329 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003330 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003331
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003332 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003333 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003334 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3335 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003336 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3337 // Check the use of this declaration
3338 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3339 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003340
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003341 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003342 MemberLoc,
3343 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003344 }
3345 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3346 // Check the use of this method.
3347 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3348 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003349 Selector SetterSel =
3350 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3351 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3352 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3353 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3354 SetterSel, Context))
3355 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3356 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3357 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3358 SMD,
3359 MemberLoc,
3360 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003361 }
3362 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003363
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003364 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003366 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003367
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003368 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3369 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003370 if (!IsArrow)
3371 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3372 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003373 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3374 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003375
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003376 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003377 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003378 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3379 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003380 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003381 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003382 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003383
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003384 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003385 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003386 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003387 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3388 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003389 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003390 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003391 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003392 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003393
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003394 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3395 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3396
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003397 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003398}
3399
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003400/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3401/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3402/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3403/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3404/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3405///
3406/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3407/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3408/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3409/// only be called
3410/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3411/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3412/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003413ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003414 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3415 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003416 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003417 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003418 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003419 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3420 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3421 return ExprError();
3422
3423 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3424
3425 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003426 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003427 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3428 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003429 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003430
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003431 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003432 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3433
3434 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3435 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3436 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3437
3438 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003439 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003440 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3441 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003442
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003443 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3444 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003445 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003446 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3447 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003448 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003449 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003450 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003451 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3452 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003453
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003454 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3455 Owned(Base);
3456 return ExprError();
3457 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003458
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003459 if (Result.get()) {
3460 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3461 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3462 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3463 // call now.
3464 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3465 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003466 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003467
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003468 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003469 }
3470
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003471 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003472 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3473 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003474 }
3475
3476 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003477}
3478
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003479ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003480 FunctionDecl *FD,
3481 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3482 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003483 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003484 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3485 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003486 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003487 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003488 return ExprError();
3489 }
3490
3491 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3492 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003493
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003494 // Instantiate the expression.
3495 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3496 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003497
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003498 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3499 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3500 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3501 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003502
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003503 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3504 if (Result.isInvalid())
3505 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003507 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3508 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003509 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003510 InitializationKind Kind
3511 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3512 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3513 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003514
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003515 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3516 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3517 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3518 if (Result.isInvalid())
3519 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003520
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003521 // Build the default argument expression.
3522 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3523 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003524 }
3525
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003526 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3527 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3528 // be properly destroyed.
3529 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3530 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003531 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3532 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3533 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3534 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3535 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3536 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003537
3538 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003539 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3540 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003541 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003542 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003543}
3544
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3546/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3547/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3548/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3549/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3550/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003551bool
3552Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003554 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3556 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003557 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3559 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003560 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003561
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3563 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3564 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3565 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3566 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003567 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003568 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003569 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003570 }
3571
3572 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3573 // them.
3574 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3575 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3576 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3577 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003578 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003579 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003580 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3581 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3582 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003583 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003584 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003585 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003587 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003589 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3590 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3591 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3592 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3593 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003594 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003595 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003596 if (Invalid)
3597 return true;
3598 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3599 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3600 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003602 return false;
3603}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003604
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003605bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3606 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3607 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3608 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3609 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3610 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003611 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003612 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3613 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3614 bool Invalid = false;
3615 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3616 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3617 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3618 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003619 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003620 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003621 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003622
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003623 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003624 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3625 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003626
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003627 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3628 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003629 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003630 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003631 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003632
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003633 // Pass the argument
3634 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3635 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3636 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003637
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003638 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003639 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3640 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003641 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003642 SourceLocation(),
3643 Owned(Arg));
3644 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3645 return true;
3646
3647 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003648 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003649 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003650
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003651 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003652 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003653 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3654 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003655
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003656 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003657 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003658 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003659 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003662 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003663 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003664 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003665 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003666 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003667 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003668 }
3669 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003670 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003671}
3672
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003673/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003674/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3675/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003676ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003677Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003678 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003679 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003680
3681 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003682 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003683 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3684 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003685
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003686 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003687
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003688 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003689 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3690 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3691 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3692 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3693 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003694 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003695 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3696 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003698 NumArgs = 0;
3699 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003700
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003701 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3702 RParenLoc));
3703 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003704
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003705 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003706 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003707 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3708 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003709 bool Dependent = false;
3710 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3711 Dependent = true;
3712 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3713 Dependent = true;
3714
3715 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003716 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003717 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3718
3719 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3720 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3721 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003722 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003723
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3725
3726 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3727 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3728 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3729 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3730 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3731 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3732 // method template.
3733 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003734 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3735 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003736 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003737
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003738 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003739 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003740 }
3741
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003742 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003743 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003744 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003745 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003746 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003747 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003748 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003749
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003750 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003751 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003752 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3753 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003754 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3755 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003756 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003757
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003758 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3759 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3760 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3761 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003762
3763 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3764 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003765 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003766 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003767
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003768 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003769 RParenLoc))
3770 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003771
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003772 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003773 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003774 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003775 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3776 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003777 }
3778 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003779 }
3780
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003781 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003782 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003783 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003784
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003785 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00003786 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3787 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
3788 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3789 RParenLoc);
3790 }
3791
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003792 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003793 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3794 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3795 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3796
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003797 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3798 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3799
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003800 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3801}
3802
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003803/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3804/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003805/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3806/// block-pointer type.
3807///
3808/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003809ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003810Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3811 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3812 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3813 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3814 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3815
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003816 // Promote the function operand.
3817 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3818
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003819 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3820 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003821 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3822 Args, NumArgs,
3823 Context.BoolTy,
3824 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003825
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003826 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3827 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3828 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3829 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003830 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003831 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003832 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3833 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003834 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003835 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003836 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003837 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003838 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003839 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003840 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3841 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3842
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003843 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003844 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003845 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003846 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003847 return ExprError();
3848
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003849 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003850 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003851
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003852 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003853 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003854 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003855 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003856 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003857 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003858
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003859 if (FDecl) {
3860 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3861 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3862 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003863 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003864 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3865 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3866 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003867 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3868 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003869 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003870
3871 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3872 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3873 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3874 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003875 }
3876
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003877 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3879 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003880
3881 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003882 InitializedEntity Entity
3883 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3884 Proto->getArgType(i));
3885 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3886 SourceLocation(),
3887 Owned(Arg));
3888 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3889 return true;
3890
3891 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3892
3893 } else {
3894 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003895 }
3896
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003897 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3898 Arg->getType(),
3899 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3900 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3901 return ExprError();
3902
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003903 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003904 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003905 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003906
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003907 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3908 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003909 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3910 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003911
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003912 // Check for sentinels
3913 if (NDecl)
3914 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003915
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003916 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003917 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003918 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003919 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003920
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003921 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003923 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003924 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003925 return ExprError();
3926 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003927
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003928 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003929}
3930
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003931ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003932Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003933 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003934 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003935 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003936 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003937
3938 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3939 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3940 if (!TInfo)
3941 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3942
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003943 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003944}
3945
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003946ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003947Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003948 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003949 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003950
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003951 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00003952 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
3953 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
3954 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
3955 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
3956 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003957 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003958 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3959 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003960 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3961 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003962 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003963 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003964 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003965 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003966
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003967 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003968 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003969 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003971 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003972 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003973 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003974 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003975 &literalType);
3976 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003977 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003978 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003979
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003980 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003981 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003982 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003983 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003984 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003985
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003986 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003987 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003988}
3989
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003990ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003991Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003992 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3993 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003994 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003995
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003996 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003997 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003998
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003999 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4000 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004001 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004002 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004003}
4004
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004005static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004006 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004007 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004008 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004009
4010 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
4011 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004012 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004013 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4014 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004015 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004016 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004017 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004018
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004019 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
4020 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004021 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004022 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004023 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004024 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004025 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004026 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004027
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004028 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4029 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004030 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004031 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004032 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004033 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004034
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004035 // FIXME: Assert here.
4036 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004037 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004038}
4039
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004040/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004041bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004042 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004043 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004044 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004045 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004046 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4047 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4048 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004049 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004050
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004051 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004052
4053 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4054 // type needs to be scalar.
4055 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4056 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004057 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004058 return false;
4059 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004060
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004061 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4062 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4063 return true;
4064
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004065 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004066 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004067 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4068 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004069 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004070 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4071 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004072 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004073 return false;
4074 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004075
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004076 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004077 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004078 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004079 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004080 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004081 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004082 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004083 castExpr->getType()) &&
4084 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004085 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4086 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4087 break;
4088 }
4089 }
4090 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4091 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4092 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004093 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004094 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004095 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004096
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004097 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4098 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4099 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4100 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004101
4102 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004103 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004104 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4105 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004106 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004107 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004108
4109 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004110 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004111
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004112 if (castType->isVectorType())
4113 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4114 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4115 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4116
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004117 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4118 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004119
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004120 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004121 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004122 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004123 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004124 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4125 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4126 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4127 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004128 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004129 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4130 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4131 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004132 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004133
4134 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004135
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004136 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004137 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4138
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004139 return false;
4140}
4141
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004142bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004143 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004144 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004145
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004146 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004147 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004148 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004149 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004150 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004151 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004152 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004153 } else
4154 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004155 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004156 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004157
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004158 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004159 return false;
4160}
4161
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004162bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004163 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004164 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004165
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004166 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004167
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004168 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4169 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004170 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4171 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4172 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4173 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004174 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004175 return false;
4176 }
4177
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004178 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004179 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4180 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004181 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4182 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4183 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4184 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004185
4186 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4187 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4188 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004189
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004190 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004191 return false;
4192}
4193
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004194ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004195Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004196 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4197 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004198 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004199
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004200 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4201 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4202 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004203 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004204
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004205 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4206 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004207 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004208 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004209
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004210 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004211}
4212
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004213ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004214Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004215 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004216 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004217 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004218 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004219 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004220 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004221
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004222 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004223 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004224 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4225 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004226}
4227
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004228/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4229/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004230ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004231Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004232 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4233 if (!E)
4234 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004235
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004236 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004237
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004238 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004239 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4240 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004241
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004242 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4243
4244 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004245}
4246
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004247ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004248Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004249 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004250 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004251 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004252 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004253 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004254
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004255 // Check for an altivec literal,
4256 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004257 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4258 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4259 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4260 return ExprError();
4261 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004262 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4263 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4264 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4265 }
4266 else
4267 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4268 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004269
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004270 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4271 // then handle it as such.
4272 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004273 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4274 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4275 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4276
4277 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4278 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004279 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4280 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004281 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4282 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004283 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004284 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004285 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004286 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004287 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004288 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4289 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004290 }
4291}
4292
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004293ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004294 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004295 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004296 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004297 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4298 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004299 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4300 Expr *expr;
4301 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4302 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4303 else
4304 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004305 return Owned(expr);
4306}
4307
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004308/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4309/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004310/// C99 6.5.15
4311QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004312 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004313 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004314 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4315 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4316 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4317 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4318 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4319 return QualType();
4320
4321 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4322 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4323 return QualType();
4324
4325 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4326 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4327 }
4328
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004329 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4330 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004331 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004332
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004333 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004334 if (SAVE) {
4335 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4336 }
4337 else
4338 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004339 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4340 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4341 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4342 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004343
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004344 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004345 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004346 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4347 // Throw an error if its not either.
4348 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4349 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4350 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4351 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4352 << CondTy;
4353 return QualType();
4354 }
4355 }
4356 else {
4357 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4358 << CondTy;
4359 return QualType();
4360 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004361 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004362
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004363 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004364 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4365 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004366
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004367 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4368 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4369 // built in select.
4370 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4371 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4372 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4373 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4374 << CondTy;
4375 return QualType();
4376 }
4377 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4378 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4379 << CondTy;
4380 return QualType();
4381 }
4382 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4383 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4384 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4385 }
4386
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004387 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4388 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004389 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4390 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4391 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004392 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004393
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004394 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4395 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004396 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4397 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004398 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004399 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004400 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004401 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004402 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004403 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004404
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004405 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004406 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004407 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4408 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4409 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4410 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4411 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4412 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4413 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004414 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4415 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004416 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004417 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004418 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4419 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004420 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004421 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004422 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004423 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004424 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004425 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004426 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004427 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004428 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004429 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004430 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004431
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004432 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4433 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4434 QuestionLoc);
4435 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4436 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004437
4438
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004439 // Handle block pointer types.
4440 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4441 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4442 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4443 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004444 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4445 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004446 return destType;
4447 }
4448 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004449 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004450 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004451 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004452 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4453 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4454 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004455 return LHSTy;
4456 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004457 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004458 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4459 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004460
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004461 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4462 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004463 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004464 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004465 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4466 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4467 // to get a consistent AST.
4468 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004469 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4470 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004471 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004472 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004473 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004474 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4475 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004476 return LHSTy;
4477 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004478
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004479 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4480 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4481 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004482 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4483 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004484
4485 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4486 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4487 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004488 QualType destPointee
4489 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004490 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004491 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004492 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004493 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004494 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004495 return destType;
4496 }
4497 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004498 QualType destPointee
4499 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004500 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004501 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004502 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004503 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004504 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004505 return destType;
4506 }
4507
4508 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4509 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4510 return LHSTy;
4511 }
4512 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4513 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4514 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4515 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4516 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4517 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4518 // to get a consistent AST.
4519 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004520 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4521 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004522 return incompatTy;
4523 }
4524 // The pointer types are compatible.
4525 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4526 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4527 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4528 // type.
4529 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4530 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004531 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4532 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004533 return LHSTy;
4534 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004536 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4537 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4538 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4539 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004540 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004541 return RHSTy;
4542 }
4543 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4544 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4545 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004546 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004547 return LHSTy;
4548 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004549
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004550 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004551 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4552 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004553 return QualType();
4554}
4555
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004556/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4557/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4558QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4559 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4560 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4561 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004562
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004563 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4564 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4565 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4566 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4567 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004568 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004569 return LHSTy;
4570 }
4571 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4572 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004573 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004574 return RHSTy;
4575 }
4576 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4577 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4578 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004579 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004580 return LHSTy;
4581 }
4582 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4583 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004584 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004585 return RHSTy;
4586 }
4587 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4588 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4589 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004590 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004591 return LHSTy;
4592 }
4593 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4594 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004595 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004596 return RHSTy;
4597 }
4598 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4599 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004600
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004601 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4602 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4603 return LHSTy;
4604 }
4605 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4606 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4607 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004608
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004609 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4610 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4611 // type. This allows
4612 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4613 // where B is a subclass of A.
4614 //
4615 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4616 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4617 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4618 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004619
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004620 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4621 // It could return the composite type.
4622 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4623 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4624 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4625 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4626 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4627 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4628 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4629 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4630 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4631 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4632 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4633 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4634 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4635 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004636 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004637 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4638 ;
4639 else {
4640 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4641 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4642 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4643 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004644 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4645 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004646 return incompatTy;
4647 }
4648 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004649 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4650 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004651 return compositeType;
4652 }
4653 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4654 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4655 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4656 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4657 QualType destPointee
4658 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4659 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4660 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004661 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004662 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004663 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004664 return destType;
4665 }
4666 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4667 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4668 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4669 QualType destPointee
4670 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4671 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4672 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004673 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004674 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004675 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004676 return destType;
4677 }
4678 return QualType();
4679}
4680
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004681/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004682/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004683ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004684 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004685 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4686 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004687 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4688 // was the condition.
4689 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004690 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4691 if (isLHSNull) {
4692 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4693 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004694
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004695 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4696 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004697 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004698 return ExprError();
4699
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004700 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004701 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4702 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4703 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004704}
4705
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004706// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004708// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4709// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4710// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004711Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004712Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4713 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004715 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4716 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4717 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4718 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4719 return Compatible;
4720 }
4721
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004722 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004723 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4724 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004725
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004726 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004727 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4728 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004729
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004730 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004731
4732 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4733 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4734 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004735 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004736 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004737 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004738
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004739 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4740 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004741 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004742 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004743 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004744 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004745
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004746 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004747 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4748 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004749 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004750
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004751 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004752 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004753 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004754
4755 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004756 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4757 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004758 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004759 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004760 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004761 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4762 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4763 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4764 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4765 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4766 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004767 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004768 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004769 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004770 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004771
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004772 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004773 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004774 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004775 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004776
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004777 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4778 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4779 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4780 // warning can be disabled.
4781 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4782 return ConvTy;
4783 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4784 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004785
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004786 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4787 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4788 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4789 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4790 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4791 do {
4792 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4793 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004794
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004795 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4796 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4797 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004798
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004799 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004800 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004801 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004802
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004803 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004804 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004805 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004806 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004807}
4808
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004809/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4810/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4811/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4812// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004813Sema::AssignConvertType
4814Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004815 QualType rhsType) {
4816 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004817
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004818 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004819 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4820 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004821
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004822 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4823 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4824 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004825
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004826 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004827
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004828 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004829 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004830 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004831
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004832 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4833 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4834 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4835 }
4836 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004837 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004838 return ConvTy;
4839}
4840
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004841/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4842/// for assignment compatibility.
4843Sema::AssignConvertType
4844Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004845 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4846 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004847 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4848 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004849 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004850 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004851 }
4852 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4853 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004854 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4855 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004856 return IncompatiblePointer;
4857 return Compatible;
4858 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004859 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004860 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004861 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004862 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4863 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4864 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4865 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4866 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4867 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004868
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004869 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4870 return Compatible;
4871 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4872 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004873 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004874}
4875
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004876/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4877/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004878/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4879///
4880/// int a, *pint;
4881/// short *pshort;
4882/// struct foo *pfoo;
4883///
4884/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4885/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4886/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4887/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4888///
4889/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004890/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004891///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004892Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004893Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004894 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4895 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004896 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4897 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004898
4899 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004900 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004901
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004902 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4903 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4904 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4905 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4906 return Compatible;
4907 }
4908
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004909 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4910 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4911 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4912 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4913 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4914 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4915 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004916 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004917 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004918 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004919 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004920 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004921 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4922 // to the same ExtVector type.
4923 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4924 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4925 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004926 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004927 return Compatible;
4928 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004929
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004930 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004931 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4932 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4933 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4934 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4935 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4936 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004937 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004938
4939 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4940 // vector type and vice versa
4941 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4942 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004943 }
4944 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004945 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004946
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004947 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4948 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004949 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004950
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004951 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004952 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004953 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004954
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004955 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004956 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004957
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004958 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004959 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004960 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4961 return Compatible;
4962 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004963 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004964 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4965 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004966 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004967
4968 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004969 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004970 return Compatible;
4971 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004972 return Incompatible;
4973 }
4974
4975 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4976 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004977 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004978
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004979 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004980 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004981 return Compatible;
4982
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004983 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4984 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004985
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004986 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004987 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004988 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004989 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004990 return Incompatible;
4991 }
4992
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004993 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4994 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4995 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004996
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004997 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004998 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004999 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5000 return Compatible;
5001 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005002 }
5003 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005004 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005005 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005006 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005007 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5008 return Compatible;
5009 }
5010 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5011 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5012 return Compatible;
5013 return Incompatible;
5014 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005015 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005016 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005017 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5018 return Compatible;
5019
5020 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005021 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005022
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005023 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005024 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005025
5026 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005027 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005028 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005029 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005030 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005031 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5032 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
5033 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5034 return Compatible;
5035
5036 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
5037 return PointerToInt;
5038
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005039 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005040 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005041 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5042 return Compatible;
5043 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005044 }
5045 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005046 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005047 return Compatible;
5048 return Incompatible;
5049 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005050
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005051 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005052 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005053 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005054 }
5055 return Incompatible;
5056}
5057
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005058/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5059/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005060static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005061 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5062 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5063 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005064 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005065 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005066 SourceLocation());
5067 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5068 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5069
5070 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5071 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005072 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005073 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005074 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005075}
5076
5077Sema::AssignConvertType
5078Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5079 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5080
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005081 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005082 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5083 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005084 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005085 return Incompatible;
5086
5087 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5088 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5089 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5090 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005091 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5092 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005093 it != itend; ++it) {
5094 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5095 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5096 // 1) void pointer
5097 // 2) null pointer constant
5098 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005099 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005100 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005101 InitField = *it;
5102 break;
5103 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005105 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005106 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005107 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005108 InitField = *it;
5109 break;
5110 }
5111 }
5112
5113 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5114 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005115 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005116 InitField = *it;
5117 break;
5118 }
5119 }
5120
5121 if (!InitField)
5122 return Incompatible;
5123
5124 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5125 return Compatible;
5126}
5127
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005128Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005129Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005130 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5131 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5132 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5133 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5134 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005135 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005136 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005137 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005138 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005139 }
5140
5141 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5142 // structures.
5143 }
5144
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005145 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5146 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005147 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5148 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005149 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005150 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005151 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005152 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005153 return Compatible;
5154 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005155
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005156 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005157 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005158 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005159 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005160 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005161 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005162 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005163 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005164
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005165 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5166 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005167
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005168 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5169 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005170 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5171 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5172 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5173 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005174 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005175 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005176 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005177 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005178}
5179
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005180QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005181 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005182 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005183 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005184 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005185}
5186
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005187QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005189 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005190 QualType lhsType =
5191 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5192 QualType rhsType =
5193 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005194
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005195 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005196 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005197 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005198
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005199 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5200 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005201 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005202 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005203 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005204 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005205 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005206 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005207 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005208 return lhsType;
5209 }
5210
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005211 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005212 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005213 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5214 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5215 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5216 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5217 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5218 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005219 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005220 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005221 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005222 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005223
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005224 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5225 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5226 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005227 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005228 return rhsType;
5229 }
5230
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005231 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5232 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5233 bool swapped = false;
5234 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5235 swapped = true;
5236 std::swap(rex, lex);
5237 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5238 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005239
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005240 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005241 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005242 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005243 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005244 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005245 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005246 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5247 return lhsType;
5248 }
5249 }
5250 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5251 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5252 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005253 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005254 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5255 return lhsType;
5256 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005257 }
5258 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005259
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005260 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005261 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005262 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005263 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005264 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005265}
5266
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005267QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5268 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005269 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005270 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005271
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005272 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005273
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005274 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5275 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5276 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005277
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005278 // Check for division by zero.
5279 if (isDiv &&
5280 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005281 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005282 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005283
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005284 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005285}
5286
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005287QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005288 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005289 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005290 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5291 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005292 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5293 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5294 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005295
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005296 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005297
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005298 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5299 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005300
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005301 // Check for remainder by zero.
5302 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005303 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5304 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005305
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005306 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005307}
5308
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005309QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005310 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005311 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5312 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5313 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5314 return compType;
5315 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005316
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005317 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005318
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005319 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005320 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5321 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5322 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005323 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005324 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005325
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005326 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5327 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005328 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005329 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5330
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005331 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005332
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005333 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005334 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005335
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005336 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5337 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005338 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5339 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005340 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005341 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005342 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343
5344 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5345 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5346 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005347 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005348 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5349 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5350 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5351 return QualType();
5352 }
5353
5354 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5355 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5356 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005357 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005358 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005359 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005360 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005361 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5362 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005363 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5364 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005365 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005366 return QualType();
5367 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005368 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005369 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005370 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5371 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5372 return QualType();
5373 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005374
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005375 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005376 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5377 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5378 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5379 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5380 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005381 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005382 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5383 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005384 return PExp->getType();
5385 }
5386 }
5387
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005388 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005389}
5390
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005391// C99 6.5.6
5392QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005393 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5394 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5395 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5396 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5397 return compType;
5398 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005399
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005400 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005401
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005402 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005403
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005404 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005405 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5406 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005407 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005408 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005409 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005410
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005411 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005412 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005413 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005414
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005415 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005416
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005417 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5418 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5419 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5420 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5421 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5422 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5423 return QualType();
5424 }
5425
5426 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5427 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5428 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5429 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5430 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005431 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005432 return QualType();
5433 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005434
5435 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5436 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5437 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005439 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005440 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005441 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005442 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005443
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005444 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005445 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005446 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5447 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5448 return QualType();
5449 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005451 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005452 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5453 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5454 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5455 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5456 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5457 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005458 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005459 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5460
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005461 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005462 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005463 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005464
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005465 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005466 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005467 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005468
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005469 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5470 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5471 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5472 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5473 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5474 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5475 return QualType();
5476 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005477
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005478 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5479 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5480 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005482 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005483 return QualType();
5484 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005485
5486 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5487 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5488 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5489 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5490 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005491 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5492 << rex->getSourceRange()
5493 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005494 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005495
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005496 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5497 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5498 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5499 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5500 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5501 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5502 return QualType();
5503 }
5504 } else {
5505 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5506 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5507 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5508 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5509 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5510 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5511 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5512 return QualType();
5513 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005514 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005515
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005516 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5517 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5518 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5519 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5520 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005521 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005522 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005523
5524 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005525 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5526 }
5527 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005528
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005529 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005530}
5531
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005532static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5533 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5534 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5535 return false;
5536}
5537
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005538// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005539QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005540 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005541 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005542 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5543 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005544 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005545
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005546 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5547 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5548 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5549 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5550 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5551 }
5552
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005553 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5554 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5555 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5556
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005557 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5558 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005559 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5560 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5561 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5562 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5563 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005564 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005565 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005566 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005567
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005568 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005569
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005570 // Sanity-check shift operands
5571 llvm::APSInt Right;
5572 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005573 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5574 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005575 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005576 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5577 else {
5578 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5579 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5580 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5581 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5582 }
5583 }
5584
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005585 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005586 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005587}
5588
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005589static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5590 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5591 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5592 return true;
5593 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5594 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5595 }
5596 return false;
5597}
5598
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005599// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005600QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005601 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005602 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005603
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005604 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005605 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005606 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005607
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005608 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5609 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005610
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005611 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005612 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5613 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5614 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005615 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5616 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5617 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005618 //
5619 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5620 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5621 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5622 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5623 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5624 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005625 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5626 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005627 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005628 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005629 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005630 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005631 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5632 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005633 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5634 || Opc == BO_LE
5635 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005636 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5637 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5638 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5639 // what is it always going to eval to?
5640 char always_evals_to;
5641 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005642 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005643 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5644 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005645 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005646 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5647 break;
5648 default:
5649 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5650 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5651 break;
5652 }
5653 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5654 << 1 // array
5655 << always_evals_to);
5656 }
5657 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005658 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005659
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005660 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5661 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5662 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5663 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005664
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005665 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5666 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005667 Expr *literalString = 0;
5668 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005669 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005670 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005671 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005672 literalString = lex;
5673 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005674 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5675 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005676 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005677 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005678 literalString = rex;
5679 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5680 }
5681
5682 if (literalString) {
5683 std::string resultComparison;
5684 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005685 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5686 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5687 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5688 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5689 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5690 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005691 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5692 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005693
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005694 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5695 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5696 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005697 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005698 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005699 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005700
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005701 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5702 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5703 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5704 else {
5705 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5706 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5707 }
5708
5709 lType = lex->getType();
5710 rType = rex->getType();
5711
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005712 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005713 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005714
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005715 if (isRelational) {
5716 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005717 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005718 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005719 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005720 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005721 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005722
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005723 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005724 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005725 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005726
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005727 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005728 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005729 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005730 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005731
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005732 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5733 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005734 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005735 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005736 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005737 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005738 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005739
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005740 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005741 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5742 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005743 if (!isRelational &&
5744 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5745 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5746 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005747 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5748 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005749 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5750 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005751 Diag(Loc,
5752 isSFINAEContext()?
5753 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5754 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005755 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005756
5757 if (isSFINAEContext())
5758 return QualType();
5759
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005760 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005761 return ResultTy;
5762 }
5763 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005764
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005765 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5766 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5767 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5768 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5769 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5770 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005771 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005772 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005773 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005774 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005775 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005776 if (T.isNull()) {
5777 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5778 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5779 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005780 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005781 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005782 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005783 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005784 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005785 }
5786
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005787 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5788 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005789 return ResultTy;
5790 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005791 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5792 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5793 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5794 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5795 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5796 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5797 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5798 }
5799 } else if (!isRelational &&
5800 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5801 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5802 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5803 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5804 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5805 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5806 }
5807 } else {
5808 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005809 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005810 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005811 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005812 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005813 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005814 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005815 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005816
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005817 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005818 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
5819 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5820 return ResultTy;
5821
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005822 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005823 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005824 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005825 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005826 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005827 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5828 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005829 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5830 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005831 return ResultTy;
5832 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005833 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005834 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005835 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005836 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5837 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005838 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5839 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005840 return ResultTy;
5841 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005842
5843 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005844 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005845 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5846 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005847 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5848 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5849 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5850 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5851 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5852 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5853 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5854 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005855 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005856 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005857 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005858 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005859 if (T.isNull()) {
5860 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005861 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005862 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005863 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005864 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005865 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005866 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005867 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005868 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005869
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005870 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5871 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005872 return ResultTy;
5873 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005874 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005875
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005876 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005877 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005878 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5879 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005880
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005881 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005882 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005883 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005884 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005885 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005886 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005887 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005888 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005889 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005890 if (!isRelational
5891 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5892 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005893 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005894 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005895 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005896 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005897 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5898 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5899 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005900 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005901 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005902 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005903 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005904
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005905 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005906 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005907 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5908 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005909 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005910 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005911 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005912 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005913
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005914 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5915 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005916 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005917 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005918 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005919 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005920 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005921 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005922 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005923 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005924 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5925 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005926 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005927 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005928 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005929 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005930 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5931 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005932 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005933 bool isError = false;
5934 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5935 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5936 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005937 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005938 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005939 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005940 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5941 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5942 isError = true;
5943 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005944 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005945
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005946 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005947 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005948 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005949 if (isError)
5950 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005951 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005952
5953 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005954 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005955 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005956 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005957 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005958 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005959
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005960 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005961 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5962 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005963 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005964 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005965 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005966 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5967 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005968 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005969 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005970 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005971 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005972}
5973
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005974/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005975/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005976/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5977/// types.
5978QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005979 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005980 bool isRelational) {
5981 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5982 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005983 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005984 if (vType.isNull())
5985 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005986
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005987 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5988 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005989
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005990 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5991 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5992 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005993 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005994 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5995 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5996 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005997 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5998 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5999 << 0 // self-
6000 << 2 // "a constant"
6001 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006002 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006003
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006004 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006005 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6006 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006007 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006008 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006009
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006010 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6011 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6012 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006013 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006014 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006015
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006016 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006017 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006018 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006019 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006020 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006021 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6022
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006023 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006024 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006025 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6026}
6027
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006028inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006029 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006030 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6031 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6032 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6033 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6034
6035 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6036 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006037
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006038 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006039
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006040 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6041 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006042 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006043 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006044}
6045
6046inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006047 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6048
6049 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6050 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6051 // is a constant.
6052 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006053 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006054 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006055 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6056 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6057 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6058 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6059 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6060 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6061 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6062 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6063 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006064 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6065 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006066 }
6067 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006068
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006069 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6070 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6071 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006072
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006073 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6074 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006075
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006076 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006077 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006078
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006079 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6080 // non-overloadable operands.
6081
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006082 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6083 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006084 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6085 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6086 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006087 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006088
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006089 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6090 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6091 // The result is a bool.
6092 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006093}
6094
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006095/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6096/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6097/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6098///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006099static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006100 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6101 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6102 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006103 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6104 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6105 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6106
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006107 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006108 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6109 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6110 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6111 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006112 }
6113 }
6114 return false;
6115}
6116
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006117/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6118/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6119static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006120 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006121 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006122 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006123 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6124 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006125 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6126 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006127
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006128 unsigned Diag = 0;
6129 bool NeedType = false;
6130 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006131 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006132 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006133 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6134 NeedType = true;
6135 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006136 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006137 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6138 NeedType = true;
6139 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006140 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006141 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6142 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006143 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6144 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006145 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006146 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6147 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006148 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6149 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006150 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6151 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006152 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006153 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006154 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006155 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006156 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6157 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006158 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006159 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6160 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006161 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6162 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6163 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006164 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6165 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6166 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006167 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6168 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6169 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006170 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006171
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006172 SourceRange Assign;
6173 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6174 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006175 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006176 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006177 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006178 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006179 return true;
6180}
6181
6182
6183
6184// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006185QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6186 SourceLocation Loc,
6187 QualType CompoundType) {
6188 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6189 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006190 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006191
6192 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6193 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006194 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006195 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006196 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006197 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006198 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006199 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006200 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6201 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6202 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006203 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006204 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006205 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006206 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006207
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006208 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6209 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6210 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006211 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006212 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6213 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6214 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006215 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6216 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006217 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006218 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006219 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6220 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6221 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006222 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6223 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006224 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006225 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006226 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006227 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006228 }
6229 } else {
6230 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006231 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006232 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006233
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006234 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006235 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006236 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006237
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006238
6239 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6240 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6241 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6242 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6243 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6244 // check.
6245 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006246 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006247 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6248 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6249 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6250 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6251 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6252 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6253 }
6254
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006255 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6256 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006257 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006258 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6259 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006260 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006261 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006262 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6263 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006264}
6265
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006266// C99 6.5.17
6267QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006268 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6269
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006270 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6271 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6272 return QualType();
6273
6274 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6275 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6276 return QualType();
6277 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6278
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006279 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6280 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6281 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6282 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6283 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6284 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6285 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006286
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006287 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6288 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6289 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6290 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006291
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006292 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006293}
6294
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006295/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6296/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006297QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006298 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006299 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6300 return Context.DependentTy;
6301
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006302 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6303 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006304
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006305 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6306 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6307 if (!isInc) {
6308 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6309 return QualType();
6310 }
6311 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6312 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6313 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006314 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006315 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6316 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006317
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006318 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006319 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006320 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6321 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6322 << Op->getSourceRange();
6323 return QualType();
6324 }
6325
6326 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006327 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006328 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006329 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6330 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6331 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6332 return QualType();
6333 }
6334
6335 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006336 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006337 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006338 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006339 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006340 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006341 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006342 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006343 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006344 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6345 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6346 return QualType();
6347 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006348 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006349 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6350 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006351 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006352 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6353 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6354 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6355 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006356 } else {
6357 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006358 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006359 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006360 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006361 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006362 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006363 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006364 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006365 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6366 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6367 // operand.
6368 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6369 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006370}
6371
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006372void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6373 bool copyInit = false;
6374 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6375 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6376 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6377 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6378 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6379 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6380 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6381 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6382 }
6383 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6384 }
6385 else
6386 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6387 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6388 if (copyInit) {
6389 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006390 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006391 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6392 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6393 Owned(Arg));
6394 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006395 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006396 }
6397}
6398
6399
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006400/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006401/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006402/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6403/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6404/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6405/// - &(x) => x
6406/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6407/// - &s.xx => s
6408/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6409/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6410/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6411/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006412static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006413 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006414 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006415 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006416 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006417 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6418 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6419 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006420 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006421 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006422 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006423 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006424 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006425 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6426 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006427 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6428 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6429 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6430 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6431 }
6432 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006433 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006434 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6435 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006436
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006437 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006438 case UO_Real:
6439 case UO_Imag:
6440 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006441 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6442 default:
6443 return 0;
6444 }
6445 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006446 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006447 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006448 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006449 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6450 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006451 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006452 default:
6453 return 0;
6454 }
6455}
6456
6457/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006458/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006459/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006460/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006461/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006462/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006463/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006464QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6465 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006466 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006467 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6468 return Context.OverloadTy;
6469
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006470 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6471 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6472 OrigOp = PR.take();
6473
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006474 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6475 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006476
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006477 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6478 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6479 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006480 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006481 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6482 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6483 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6484 }
6485 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6486 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6487 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006488 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006489 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006490
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006491 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006492 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6493 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6494 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6495 if (isSFINAEContext())
6496 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006497 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006498 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006499 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6500 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6501 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6502
6503 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6504 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6505 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6506 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6507 return QualType();
6508 }
6509 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6510 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6511
6512 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6513 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6514 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6515 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6516
6517 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6518 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6519 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6520 << op->getSourceRange();
6521 }
6522
6523 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6524 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6525 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006526 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006527 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006528 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006529 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006530 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6531 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006532 return QualType();
6533 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006534 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006535 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6536 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6537 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006538 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006539 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006540 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006541 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006542 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006543 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006544 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6545 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6546 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6547 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6548 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006549 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6550 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006551 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6552 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006553 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006554 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006555 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6556 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006557 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6558 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006559 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006560 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006561 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6562 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006563 return QualType();
6564 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006565 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006566 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006567 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006568 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006569 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6570 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006571 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006572 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006573 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6574 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006575 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006576 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6577 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6578 return QualType();
6579 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006580
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006581 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6582 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006583 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006584 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006585 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006586 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006587 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006588
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006589 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6590 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6591 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6592 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6593 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6594 }
6595
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006596 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006597 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6598 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006599 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6600}
6601
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006602/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006603QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006604 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6605 return Context.DependentTy;
6606
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006607 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006608 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6609 QualType Result;
6610
6611 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6612 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6613 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6614 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6615 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6616 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6617 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6618 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6619 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006620 else {
6621 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6622 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6623 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6624 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006625
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006626 if (Result.isNull()) {
6627 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6628 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6629 return QualType();
6630 }
6631
6632 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006633}
6634
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006635static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006636 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006637 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006638 switch (Kind) {
6639 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006640 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6641 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6642 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6643 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6644 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6645 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6646 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6647 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6648 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6649 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6650 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6651 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6652 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6653 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6654 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6655 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6656 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6657 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6658 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6659 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6660 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6661 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6662 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6663 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6664 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6665 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6666 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6667 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6668 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6669 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6670 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6671 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006672 }
6673 return Opc;
6674}
6675
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006676static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006677 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006678 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006679 switch (Kind) {
6680 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006681 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6682 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6683 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6684 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6685 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6686 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6687 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6688 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6689 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6690 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6691 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006692 }
6693 return Opc;
6694}
6695
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006696/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6697/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6698/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006699ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006700 unsigned Op,
6701 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006702 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006703 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006704 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6705 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6706 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006707
6708 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006709 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006710 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6711 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006712 case BO_PtrMemD:
6713 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006714 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006715 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006716 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006717 case BO_Mul:
6718 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006719 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006720 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006721 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006722 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006723 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6724 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006725 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006726 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6727 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006728 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006729 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6730 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006731 case BO_Shl:
6732 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006733 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6734 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006735 case BO_LE:
6736 case BO_LT:
6737 case BO_GE:
6738 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006739 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006740 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006741 case BO_EQ:
6742 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006743 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006744 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006745 case BO_And:
6746 case BO_Xor:
6747 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006748 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6749 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006750 case BO_LAnd:
6751 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006752 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006753 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006754 case BO_MulAssign:
6755 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006756 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006757 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006758 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6759 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6760 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006761 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006762 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006763 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6764 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6765 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6766 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006767 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006768 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006769 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6770 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6771 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006772 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006773 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006774 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6775 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6776 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006777 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006778 case BO_ShlAssign:
6779 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006780 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6781 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6782 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6783 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006784 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006785 case BO_AndAssign:
6786 case BO_XorAssign:
6787 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006788 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6789 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6790 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6791 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006792 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006793 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006794 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6795 break;
6796 }
6797 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006798 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006799 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006800 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006801 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6802 << ResultTy;
6803 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006804 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006805 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6806 else
6807 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006808 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6809 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006810}
6811
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006812/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6813/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006814static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6815 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006816 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6817 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6818 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006819 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006820 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6821
6822 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6823 return;
6824
6825 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6826 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6827 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006828 return;
6829 }
6830
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006831 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6832 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006833 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006834
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006835 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006836 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006837
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006838 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6839 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6840 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6841 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006842 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006843 return;
6844 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006845
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006846 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006847 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6848 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006849}
6850
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006851/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6852/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6853/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6854/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006855static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006856 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006857 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6858 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6859 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6860 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006861 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006862 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006863 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6864
6865 // Subs are not binary operators.
6866 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6867 return;
6868
6869 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6870 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006871 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6872 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006873 return;
6874
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006875 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006876 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006877 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006878 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6879 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006880 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006881 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006882 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6883 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6884 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6885 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006886 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006887 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006888 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006889 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6890 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006891 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006892 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006893 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6894 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6895 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6896 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006897}
6898
6899/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6900/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6901/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006902static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006903 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006904 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006905 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6906}
6907
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006908// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006909ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006910 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6911 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6912 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006913 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6914 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006915
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006916 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6917 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6918
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006919 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6920}
6921
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006922ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006923 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6924 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006925 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006926 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6927 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006928 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006929 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006930 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6931 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6932 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6933 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6934 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006935 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006936 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006937 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6938 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6939 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006940
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006941 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6942 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006943 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006944 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006945
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006946 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006947 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006948}
6949
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006950ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006951 unsigned OpcIn,
6952 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006953 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006954
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006955 QualType resultType;
6956 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006957 case UO_PreInc:
6958 case UO_PreDec:
6959 case UO_PostInc:
6960 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006961 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006962 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6963 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6964 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6965 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006966 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006967 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006968 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6969 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006970 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006971 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006972 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6973 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006974 case UO_Plus:
6975 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006976 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6977 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006978 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6979 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006980 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6981 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006982 break;
6983 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6984 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6985 break;
6986 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006987 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006988 resultType->isPointerType())
6989 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006990 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6991 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6992 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6993 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6994 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006995
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006996 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6997 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006998 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006999 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7000 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007001 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7002 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007003 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7004 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7005 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007006 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007007 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007008 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7009 break;
7010 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7011 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7012 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7013 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7014 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007015 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7016 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007017 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007018 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007019 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007020 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007021 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007022 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007023 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7024 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007025 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7026 // ok, fallthrough
7027 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7028 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7029 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7030 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7031 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007032 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7033 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007034 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007035
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007036 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007037 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7038 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007039 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007040 case UO_Real:
7041 case UO_Imag:
7042 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007043 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007044 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007045 resultType = Input->getType();
7046 break;
7047 }
7048 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007049 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007050
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007051 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007052}
7053
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007054ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007055 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7056 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007057 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007058 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007059 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7060 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7061 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7062 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007063 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007064 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007065 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7066 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7067 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007068
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007069 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007070 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007071
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007072 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007073}
7074
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007075// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007076ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007077 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7078 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007079}
7080
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007081/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007082ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007083 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7084 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007085 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007086 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007087
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007088 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7089 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007090 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007091 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007092
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007093 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007094 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007095 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7096 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007097}
7098
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007099ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007100Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007101 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007102 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7103 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7104
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007105 bool isFileScope
7106 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007107 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007108 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007109
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007110 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7111 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7112 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007113
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007114 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7115 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7116 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007117 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007118 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7119 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007120 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007121 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007122 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7123 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007124 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007125 }
7126 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bdc4462010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007127 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007128 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007129 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7130 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7131 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7132 Ty,
7133 false),
7134 SourceLocation(),
7135 Owned(LastExpr));
7136 if (Res.isInvalid())
7137 return ExprError();
7138 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7139 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7140 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7141 else
7142 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7143 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7144 }
7145 }
7146 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007147 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007148
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007149 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7150 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007151 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7152 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7153 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7154 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007155}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007156
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007157ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007158 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7159 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7160 unsigned NumComponents,
7161 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007162 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007163 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007164 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007165
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007166 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7167 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7168 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007169 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007170 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7171 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7172
7173 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7174 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7175 if (!Dependent
7176 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7177 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7178 << TypeRange))
7179 return ExprError();
7180
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007181 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7182 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007183 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7184 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007185 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007186 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7187 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007188
7189 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7190 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7191 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7192 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7193 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7194 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7195 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7196 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7197 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7198 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7199 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7200 if(!AT)
7201 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7202 << CurrentType);
7203 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7204 } else
7205 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7206
7207 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7208 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7209 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7210 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7211 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7212 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7213 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7214 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7215
7216 // Record this array index.
7217 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7218 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7219 continue;
7220 }
7221
7222 // Offset of a field.
7223 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7224 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7225 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7226 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7227 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7228 continue;
7229 }
7230
7231 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7232 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7233 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7234 return ExprError();
7235
7236 // Look for the designated field.
7237 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7238 if (!RC)
7239 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7240 << CurrentType);
7241 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7242
7243 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7244 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7245 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7246 // (clause 9).
7247 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7248 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7249 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7250 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7251 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7252 << CurrentType))
7253 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7254 }
7255
7256 // Look for the field.
7257 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7258 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7259 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7260 if (!MemberDecl)
7261 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7262 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7263 OC.LocEnd));
7264
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007265 // C99 7.17p3:
7266 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7267 //
7268 // We diagnose this as an error.
7269 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7270 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7271 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7272 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7273 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7274 return ExprError();
7275 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007276
7277 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7278 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7279 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7280 do {
7281 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7282 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7283 }
7284
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007285 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7286 // the base class indirections.
7287 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7288 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007289 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007290 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7291 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7292 B != BEnd; ++B)
7293 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7294 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007295
7296 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007297 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7298 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7299 unsigned n = Path.size();
7300 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7301 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7302 } else {
7303 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7304 }
7305 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7306 }
7307
7308 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7309 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7310 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7311}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007312
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007313ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007314 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7315 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7316 ParsedType argty,
7317 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7318 unsigned NumComponents,
7319 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7320
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007321 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7322 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7323 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7324 return ExprError();
7325
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007326 if (!ArgTInfo)
7327 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7328
7329 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7330 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007331}
7332
7333
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007334ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007335 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7336 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007337 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7338 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7339 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7340 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007341
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007342 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007343
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007344 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7345}
7346
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007347ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007348Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7349 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7350 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7351 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007352 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7353 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7354 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7355 return ExprError();
7356 }
7357
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007358 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007359 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007360}
7361
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007362
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007363ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007364 Expr *CondExpr,
7365 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7366 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007367 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7368
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007369 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007370 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007371 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007372 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007373 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007374 } else {
7375 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7376 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7377 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7378 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007379 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7380 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7381 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007382
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007383 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7384 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007385 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7386 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007387 }
7388
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007389 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007390 resType, RPLoc,
7391 resType->isDependentType(),
7392 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007393}
7394
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007395//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7396// Clang Extensions.
7397//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7398
7399/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007400void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007401 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7402 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7403 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007404 if (BlockScope)
7405 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7406 else
7407 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007408}
7409
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007410void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007411 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007412 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007413
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007414 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007415 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007416 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007417
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007418 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007419 QualType RetTy;
7420 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007421 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007422 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007423 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007424 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7425 } else {
7426 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007427 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007428 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007429
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007430 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007431
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007432 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7433 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7434 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007435 return;
7436 }
7437
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007438 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7439 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7440 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7441 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7442 return;
7443 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007444
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007445 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007446 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7447 // ^ * { ... }
7448 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007449 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7450 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007451
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007452 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007453 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007454 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7455 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7456 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7457 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007458 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7459 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7460 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7461 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7462 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007463 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007464 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007465
7466 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7467 // ^ fntype { ... }
7468 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7469 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7470 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7471 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7472 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7473 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7474 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007475 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007476 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007477 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007478
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007479 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007480 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007481 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007482 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7483 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7484 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7485 }
7486
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007487 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007488 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007489
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007490 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007491 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7492 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7493 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7494 }
7495
7496 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7497 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007498 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007499 return;
7500
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007501 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7502 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7503
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007504 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007505 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7506 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7507
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007508 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007509 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7510 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7511 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7512
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007513 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007514 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007515 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007516}
7517
7518/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7519/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7520void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007521 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007522 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007523 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007524}
7525
7526/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7527/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007528ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007529 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007530 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7531 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7532 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007533
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007534 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007535
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007536 PopDeclContext();
7537
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007538 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007539 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7540 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007541
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007542 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007543 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007544
7545 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7546 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7547 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7548
7549 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7550 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7551
7552 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7553 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7554 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7555 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7556
7557 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7558 // preserve its sugar structure.
7559 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7560 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7561 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7562
7563 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7564 } else {
7565 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7566 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7567 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7568 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7569 FPT->isVariadic(),
7570 /*quals*/ 0,
7571 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7572 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7573 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7574 FPT->exception_begin(),
7575 Ext);
7576 }
7577
7578 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7579 } else {
7580 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7581 false, false, 0, 0,
7582 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7583 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007584
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007585 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7586 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007587 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007588
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007589 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007590 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007591 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007592
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007593 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007594
7595 bool Good = true;
7596 // Check goto/label use.
7597 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7598 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7599 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7600
7601 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7602 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007603 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7604 if (!L->isUsed())
7605 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007606 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007607 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007608
7609 // Emit error.
7610 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7611 Good = false;
7612 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007613 if (!Good) {
7614 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007615 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007616 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007617
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007618 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7619 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7620
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007621 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007622 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7623 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007624 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007625
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007626 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007627 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007628}
7629
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007630ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007631 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007632 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007633 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7634 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007635 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007636}
7637
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007638ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007639 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007640 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007641 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007642
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007643 // Get the va_list type
7644 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007645 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7646 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7647 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7648 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007649 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007650 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7651 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7652 } else {
7653 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7654 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007655 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007656 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007657 return ExprError();
7658 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007659
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007660 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7661 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007662 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7663 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007664 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007665 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007666
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007667 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007668 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007669
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007670 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7671 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007672}
7673
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007674ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007675 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7676 // pointers on the target.
7677 QualType Ty;
7678 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7679 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7680 else
7681 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7682
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007683 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007684}
7685
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007686static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007687 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007688 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7689 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007690
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007691 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7692 if (!PT)
7693 return;
7694
7695 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7696 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7697 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7698 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7699 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7700 return;
7701 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007703 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7704 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7705 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7706 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007707
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007708 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007709}
7710
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007711bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7712 SourceLocation Loc,
7713 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007714 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7715 bool *Complained) {
7716 if (Complained)
7717 *Complained = false;
7718
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007719 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7720 bool isInvalid = false;
7721 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007722 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007723
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007724 switch (ConvTy) {
7725 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7726 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007727 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007728 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7729 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007730 case IntToPointer:
7731 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7732 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007733 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007734 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007735 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7736 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007737 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7738 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7739 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007740 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7741 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7742 break;
7743 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007744 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7745 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7746 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7747 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7748 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7749 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7750 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7751 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7752 // C++ semantics.
7753 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7754 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7755 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007756 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7757 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007758 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007759 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007760 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007761 case IntToBlockPointer:
7762 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7763 break;
7764 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007765 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007766 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007767 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007768 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007769 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7770 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7771 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007772 case IncompatibleVectors:
7773 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7774 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007775 case Incompatible:
7776 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7777 isInvalid = true;
7778 break;
7779 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007780
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007781 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7782 switch (Action) {
7783 case AA_Assigning:
7784 case AA_Initializing:
7785 // The destination type comes first.
7786 FirstType = DstType;
7787 SecondType = SrcType;
7788 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007789
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007790 case AA_Returning:
7791 case AA_Passing:
7792 case AA_Converting:
7793 case AA_Sending:
7794 case AA_Casting:
7795 // The source type comes first.
7796 FirstType = SrcType;
7797 SecondType = DstType;
7798 break;
7799 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007800
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007801 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007802 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007803 if (Complained)
7804 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007805 return isInvalid;
7806}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007807
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007808bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007809 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7810 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7811 if (Result)
7812 *Result = ICEResult;
7813 return false;
7814 }
7815
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007816 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7817
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007818 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007819 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7820 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7821
7822 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7823 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7824 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7825 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7826 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7827 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7828 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007829
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007830 return true;
7831 }
7832
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007833 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7834 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007835
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007836 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7837 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7838 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007839
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007840 if (Result)
7841 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7842 return false;
7843}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007844
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007845void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007846Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007847 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7848 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007849}
7850
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007851void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007852Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7853 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7854 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7855 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007856
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007857 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7858 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7859 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7860 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7861 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007862 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007863 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7864 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7865 I != IEnd; ++I)
7866 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7867 }
7868
7869 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7870 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7871 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7872 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7873 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7874 I != IEnd; ++I)
7875 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7876 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007877 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007878
7879 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7880 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7881 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7882 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007883 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007884 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7885 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7886 ExprTemporaries.end());
7887
7888 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7889 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007890}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007891
7892/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7893///
7894/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7895/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7896/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7897/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7898///
7899/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7900///
7901/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7902void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7903 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007904
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007905 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007906 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007907
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007908 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7909 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7910 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7911 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007912 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007913 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007914 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007915 return;
7916 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007917
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007918 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7919 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007920
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007921 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7922 // an instantiation.
7923 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7924 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007925
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007926 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007927 case Unevaluated:
7928 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7929 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007930
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007931 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7932 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7933 // "used"; handle this below.
7934 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007935
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007936 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7937 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7938 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7939 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007940 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007941 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007942
7943 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7944 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7945 // containing expression is used.
7946 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007947 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007948
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007949 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007950 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007951 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007952 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007953 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7954 return;
7955 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7956 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007957 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007958 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007959 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007960 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7961 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007962
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007963 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007964 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007965 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007966 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007967 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7968 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007969 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7970 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7971 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007972 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007973 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007974 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7975 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007976 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007977 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007978 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007979 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007980 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007981 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7982 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7983 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7984 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7985 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007986 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007987 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007988 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007989 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007990 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7991 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7992 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007993 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007994 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007995 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7996 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007997
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007998 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7999 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8000 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8001 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8002 Loc));
8003 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008004 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008005 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008006 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8007 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8008 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008009 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008010 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8011 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008012
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008013 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008014
8015 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8016 if (CurContext != Function)
8017 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008018
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008019 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008020 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008021
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008022 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008023 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008024 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008025 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8026 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8027 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8028 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8029 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8030 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008031 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008032 }
8033 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008034
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008035 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008036
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008037 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008038 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008039 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008040}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008041
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008042namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008043 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008044 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008045 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008046 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8047 Sema &S;
8048 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008049
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008050 public:
8051 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008052
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008053 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008054
8055 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8056 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008057 };
8058}
8059
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008060bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8061 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008062 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8063 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8064 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008065
8066 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008067}
8068
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008069bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008070 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8071 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8072 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008073 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008074 }
8075
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008076 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008077}
8078
8079void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8080 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008081 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008082}
8083
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008084namespace {
8085 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8086 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8087 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8088 Sema &S;
8089
8090 public:
8091 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8092
8093 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8094
8095 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8096 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8097 }
8098
8099 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8100 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008101 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008102 }
8103
8104 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8105 if (E->getConstructor())
8106 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8107 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8108 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8109 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8110 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008111 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008112 }
8113
8114 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8115 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8116 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008117 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8118 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8119 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8120 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8121 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8122 }
8123
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008124 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008125 }
8126
8127 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8128 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008129 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008130 }
8131
8132 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8133 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8134 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008135
8136 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8137 Visit(E->getExpr());
8138 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008139 };
8140}
8141
8142/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8143/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8144void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8145 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8146}
8147
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008148/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8149/// of the program being compiled.
8150///
8151/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008152/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008153/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8154/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8155/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8156/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008157/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008158/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008159///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008160/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8161/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8162/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8163/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008164bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008165 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8166 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8167 case Unevaluated:
8168 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8169 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008170
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008171 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008172 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008173 Diag(Loc, PD);
8174 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008175
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008176 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8177 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8178 break;
8179 }
8180
8181 return false;
8182}
8183
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008184bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8185 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8186 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8187 return false;
8188
8189 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8190 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8191 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8192 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008193
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008194 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008195 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008196 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8197 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008198 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008199 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8200 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8201 return true;
8202
8203 return false;
8204}
8205
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008206// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8207// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8208void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8209 SourceLocation Loc;
8210
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008211 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8212
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008213 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8214 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008215 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008216 return;
8217
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008218 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8219 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8220 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8221 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8222
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008223 // self = [<foo> init...]
8224 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8225 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8226 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8227
8228 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8229 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8230 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8231 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8232 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008233
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008234 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8235 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8236 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8237 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8238 return;
8239
8240 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8241 } else {
8242 // Not an assignment.
8243 return;
8244 }
8245
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008246 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008247 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008248
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008249 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008250 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008251 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008252 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8253 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8254 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008255}
8256
8257bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8258 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8259
8260 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008261 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8262 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8263 << E->getSourceRange();
8264
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008265 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008266
8267 QualType T = E->getType();
8268
8269 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8270 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8271 return true;
8272 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8274 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8275 return true;
8276 }
8277 }
8278
8279 return false;
8280}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008281
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008282ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8283 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008284 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008285 return ExprError();
8286
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008287 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008288 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008289
8290 return Owned(Sub);
8291}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008292
8293/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8294/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8295ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8296 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8297 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8298
8299 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8300 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8301 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8302 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8303 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8304 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8305 Specialization->getAccess());
8306 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8307 if (!E) return ExprError();
8308 return Owned(E);
8309 }
8310
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008311 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008312 return ExprError();
8313 }
8314
8315 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8316 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8317
8318 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8319 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8320 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8321 return ExprError();
8322}